blob: 533d04f7ec9e04bc82c7a78f746008486008bbba [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000060 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000061 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000062 }
63
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000064 // See if the decl is unavailable
65 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000066 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000067 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
68 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000069
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000070 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000071 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000072 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
73 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
74 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
75 return true;
76 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000077 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000079 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080}
81
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000082/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000084/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
85///
86void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000087 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000088 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000089 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000091
92 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
93 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000094 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
95 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000096
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000097 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
98 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000099 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000100 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
101 int isMethod = 0;
102 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
103 // skip over named parameters.
104 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
105 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
106 if (nullPos)
107 --nullPos;
108 else
109 ++i;
110 }
111 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
112 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000113 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000114 // skip over named parameters.
115 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
116 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
117 if (nullPos)
118 --nullPos;
119 else
120 ++i;
121 }
122 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000123 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000124 // block or function pointer call.
125 QualType Ty = V->getType();
126 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000127 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000128 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
129 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000130 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
131 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
132 unsigned k;
133 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
134 if (nullPos)
135 --nullPos;
136 else
137 ++i;
138 }
139 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
140 }
141 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
142 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000143 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000144 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000145 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 return;
147
148 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000149 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000150 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000151 return;
152 }
153 int sentinel = i;
154 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
155 --sentinelPos;
156 ++i;
157 }
158 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
159 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000160 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000161 return;
162 }
163 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
164 ++i;
165 ++sentinel;
166 }
167 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
170 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000171 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000172 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
173 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
174 return;
175
176 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
177 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
178
179 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
180 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000181}
182
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000183SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
184 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
185 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
186}
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
189// Standard Promotions and Conversions
190//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
191
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000192/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
193void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
194 QualType Ty = E->getType();
195 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
196
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000197 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000198 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000199 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000200 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
201 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
202 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
203 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
204 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
205 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
206 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000207 //
208 // C++ 4.2p1:
209 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
210 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
211 //
212 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
213 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000214 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000215 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000216 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217}
218
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000219void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
220 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000221
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000222 QualType Ty = E->getType();
223 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
224 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
225 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
226 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
227 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
228 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
229 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
230 // rvalue is T
231 //
232 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000233 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
234 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000235 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000236 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000237 }
238}
239
240
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000241/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000242/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000243/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
244/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
245/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
246Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
247 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000249
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000250 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
251 //
252 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
253 // unsigned int may be used:
254 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
255 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
256 // and unsigned int.
257 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
258 //
259 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
260 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
261 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
262 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000263 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
264 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000266 return Expr;
267 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000268 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000269 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000270 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000272 }
273
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000274 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000275 return Expr;
276}
277
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000278/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000279/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000280/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
281void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
282 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
283 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000284
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000285 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000286 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
287 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000288 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000289
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000290 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
291}
292
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000293/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
294/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
295/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
296/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
298 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000299 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000300
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000301 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
302 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
303 // etc.
304 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
305 return false;
306
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000307 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000308 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
309 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
310 << Expr->getType() << CT))
311 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000312
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000313 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000314 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000315 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
316 << Expr->getType() << CT))
317 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000318
319 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000320}
321
322
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000323/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
324/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000326/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
327/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
328/// GCC.
329QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
330 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000331 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000332 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000333
334 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000335
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000337 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000338 QualType lhs =
339 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000340 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000341 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000342
343 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
344 if (lhs == rhs)
345 return lhs;
346
347 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
348 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
349 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
350 return lhs;
351
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000352 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000353 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000354 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
355 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000356 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000357 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
358 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
359
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000360 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000361 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000362 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
363 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000364 return destType;
365}
366
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000367//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
368// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
369//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
370
371
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000372/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000373/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
374/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
375/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
376/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000377///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000378ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000379Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000380 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
381
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000382 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000383 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000384 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000385
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000386 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000387 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
388 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000390 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000391 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000393
394 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000395 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000396 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000397
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000398 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
399 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
400 // strings.
401 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000402 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000403 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000404
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000405 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000406 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
407 Literal.GetStringLength(),
408 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
409 &StringTokLocs[0],
410 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000411}
412
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000413/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
414/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
415/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
416/// for values inside the block or for globals).
417///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000418/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000419/// up-to-date.
420///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000421static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000422 ValueDecl *VD) {
423 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
424 // we wanted to.
425 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
426 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000427
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000428 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
429 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
430 return false;
431
432 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
433 // snapshot it.
434 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
435 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000436 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
437 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000438
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000439 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
440 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
441
442 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
443 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
444 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
445 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000446 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
447 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000448
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000449 if (!NextBlock)
450 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000451
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000452 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
453 // having a reference outside it.
454 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
455 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000456
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000457 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
458 // a snapshot as well.
459 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
460 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000461
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000462 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463}
464
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000465
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000466ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000467Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000468 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000469 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
470 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
471}
472
473/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000474ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
476 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
477 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000478 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000479 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000480 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000481 << D->getDeclName();
482 return ExprError();
483 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000486 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
487 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
488 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000489 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000490 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
492 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000493 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
494 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000495 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000496 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000497 << D->getIdentifier();
498 return ExprError();
499 }
500 }
501 }
502 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000503
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000506 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
507 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
508 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000509 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000510}
511
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000512/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
513/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
514/// actual member.
515///
516/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
517/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
518/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
519/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
520/// we found.
521///
522/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
523/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
524/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
525VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
526 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
528 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
529 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
530
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000531 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
533 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
534 do {
535 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000536 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000537 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000538 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000539 else {
540 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
541 break;
542 }
543 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000545 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000546
547 return BaseObject;
548}
549
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000550ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000551Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
552 FieldDecl *Field,
553 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
554 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
555 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000556 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000557 AnonFields);
558
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000559 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
560 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
561 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
562 // found via name lookup.
563 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000564 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000565 if (BaseObject) {
566 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
567 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000568 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000569 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000570 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000571 BaseQuals
572 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000573 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
574 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
575 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
576 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
577 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000578 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
580 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
581 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000582 BaseQuals
583 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 } else {
585 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
586 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
587 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000588 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
589 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000591 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 = Context.getTagDeclType(
593 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
594 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000595 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
597 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
598 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000599 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000600 MD->getThisType(Context),
601 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
603 }
604 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000605 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
606 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000607 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000608 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 }
610
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000611 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000612 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
613 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000614 }
615
616 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
617 // anonymous struct/union.
618 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000619 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000620 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
621 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
622 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
623 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000624 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
625 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
626
627 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
628 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
629 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
630 ResultQuals.removeConst();
631
632 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
633 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
634
635 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
636 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
637
638 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
639 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
640 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
641
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000642 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000643 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000644 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000645 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
646 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000647 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000648 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 }
650
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000651 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652}
653
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000654/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000655/// possibly a list of template arguments.
656///
657/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
658/// DecomposeTemplateName.
659///
660/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
661/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
662/// some way.
663static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
664 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
665 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000666 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000667 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
668 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
669 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
670 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
671
672 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
673 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
674 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
675 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
676 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
677
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000678 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000679 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
680 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000681 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
682 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000683 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684 TemplateArgs = 0;
685 }
686}
687
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000688/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
689/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
690/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000691static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000692 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
693 return false;
694
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
696 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
697 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
698 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
699 if (!BaseRT) return false;
700
701 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000702 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000703 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
704 return false;
705 }
706
707 return true;
708}
709
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000710/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
711/// the prospective base classes.
712static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
713 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
714 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000715 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000718 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000719 if (!RD) return false;
720 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
721
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000722 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
723 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
724 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
725 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
726 if (!BaseRT) return false;
727
728 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000729 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
730 return false;
731 }
732
733 return true;
734}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000735
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000736enum IMAKind {
737 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
738 IMA_Static,
739
740 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
741 IMA_Mixed,
742
743 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
744 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
745 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
746
747 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
748 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
749 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
750
751 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
752 IMA_Instance,
753
754 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
755 IMA_Unresolved,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
758 /// context is not an instance method.
759 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
760
761 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
762 /// non-class context.
763 IMA_AnonymousMember,
764
765 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
766 /// context is not an instance method.
767 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
768
769 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
770 /// class.
771 IMA_Error_Unrelated
772};
773
774/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
775/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
776/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
777/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
778/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
779/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
780static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
781 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000782 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000783
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000784 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000785 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000786 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
787 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000788
789 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
790 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
791
792 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
793 bool hasNonInstance = false;
794 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
795 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000796 NamedDecl *D = *I;
797 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000798 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
799
800 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
801 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
802 // that's a special case.
803 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
804 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
805 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
806 }
807 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
808 }
809 else
810 hasNonInstance = true;
811 }
812
813 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
814 // member reference.
815 if (Classes.empty())
816 return IMA_Static;
817
818 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
819 // an implicit member reference.
820 if (isStaticContext)
821 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
822
823 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
824 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
825 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
826 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000827 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000828 Classes))
829 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
830
831 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
832}
833
834/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
835static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
836 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
837 const LookupResult &R) {
838 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
839 SourceRange Range(Loc);
840 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
841
842 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
843 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
844 if (MD->isStatic()) {
845 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
846 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
847 << Range << R.getLookupName();
848 return;
849 }
850 }
851
852 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
853 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
854 return;
855 }
856
857 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000858}
859
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000860/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
861///
862/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000863bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
864 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000865 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
866
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000867 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000868 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
870 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000871 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
874 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000876 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
877 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
878 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
879 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000880 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000881 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000882 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
883 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
884
885 if (!R.empty()) {
886 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
887 R.suppressDiagnostics();
888
889 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
890 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
891 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
892 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
893
894 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
895 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
896 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000898 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
899 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000900 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000902 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000903 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
904 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
905 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
906 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
907 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
908 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
909 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
910 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
911 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
912 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
913 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
914 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
915 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
916 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000917 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000918 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
919 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
920 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000921 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000923 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000924 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925
926 // Do we really want to note all of these?
927 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
928 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
929
930 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
931 return false;
932 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000933
934 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000935 }
936 }
937
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000938 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000939 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000940 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000941 if (!R.empty()) {
942 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
943 if (SS.isEmpty())
944 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
945 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
946 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
947 else
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
949 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
950 << SS.getRange()
951 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
952 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
953 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
954 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
955 << ND->getDeclName();
956
957 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
958 return false;
959 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000960
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000961 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
962 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
963 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
964 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
965 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
966 // to recover well anyway.
967 if (SS.isEmpty())
968 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
969 else
970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
971 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
972 << SS.getRange();
973
974 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
975 return true;
976 }
977 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000978 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000979 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000980 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000981 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000982 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
985 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 return true;
987 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000988 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000989 }
990
991 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
992 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
993 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
994 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
995 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
996 << SS.getRange();
997 return true;
998 }
999
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001000 // Give up, we can't recover.
1001 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1002 return true;
1003}
1004
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001005static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001006 IdentifierInfo *II,
1007 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001008 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1009 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1010 if (!IDecl)
1011 return 0;
1012 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1013 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1014 return 0;
1015 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1016 if (!property)
1017 return 0;
1018 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1019 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1020 return 0;
1021 return property;
1022}
1023
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001024static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001025 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001026 IdentifierInfo *II,
1027 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1028 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001029 bool LookForIvars;
1030 if (Lookup.empty())
1031 LookForIvars = true;
1032 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1033 LookForIvars = false;
1034 else
1035 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1036 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1037 if (!LookForIvars)
1038 return 0;
1039
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001040 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1041 if (!IDecl)
1042 return 0;
1043 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001044 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1045 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001046 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1047 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1048 if (!property)
1049 return 0;
1050 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1051 DynamicImplSeen =
1052 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1053 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001054 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1055 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001056 NameLoc,
1057 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1058 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1059 (Expr *)0, true);
1060 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1061 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1062 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1063 return Ivar;
1064 }
1065 return 0;
1066}
1067
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001068ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001069 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1070 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1071 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1072 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001073 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1074 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1075
1076 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001077 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001078
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001079 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001080
1081 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001082 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001084 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001085
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001086 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001087 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001088 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001089
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001090 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1091 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001092 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1093 // (note: handled after lookup)
1094 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1095 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1096 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001097 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1098 // names a dependent type.
1099 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1100 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001101 bool DependentID = false;
1102 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1103 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1104 DependentID = true;
1105 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1106 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1107 if (DC) {
1108 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1109 return ExprError();
1110 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1111 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1112 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1113 } else {
1114 DependentID = true;
1115 }
1116 }
1117
1118 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001119 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001120 TemplateArgs);
1121 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001122 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001124 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001126 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1127 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1128 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1129 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1130 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001131 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1132 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1133 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001134 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001135 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001136 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001137
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001138 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1139 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001140 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001141 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001142 if (E.isInvalid())
1143 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001144
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001145 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1146 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001147 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1148 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001149 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001150 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1151 isAddressOfOperand);
1152 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001153 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1154 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001155 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001156 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001157
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001158 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1159 return ExprError();
1160
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001161 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1162 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001164
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001165 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001166 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001167 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1168 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1169 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1170 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1171 }
1172
1173 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1174 // call, diagnose the problem.
1175 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001176 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001177 return ExprError();
1178
1179 assert(!R.empty() &&
1180 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001181
1182 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1183 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001184 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001185 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1186 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001187 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001188 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1189 return move(E);
1190 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001191 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001192 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001193
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1195 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1196
1197 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001198 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001199 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1200 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001201 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1202 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1203 if (Property) {
1204 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1205 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001206 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001207 }
1208 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001209 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001210 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1211 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1212 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1213 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1214 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1215 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001217 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001218
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001219 QualType T = Func->getType();
1220 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001221 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001222 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1223 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001224 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001225 }
1226 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001227
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001228 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001229 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1230 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1231 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1232 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1233 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1234 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1235 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1236 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001237 //
1238 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1239 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1240 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1241 // non-static member function:
1242 //
1243 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1244 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1245 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1246 // member function call.
1247 //
1248 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1249 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1250 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1251 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001252 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001253 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1254 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1255 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1256 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1257 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1258 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1259 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001260 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1261 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001262 else
1263 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1264
1265 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001266 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001267 }
1268
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001269 if (TemplateArgs)
1270 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001271
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1273}
1274
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001275/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001276ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001277Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1278 LookupResult &R,
1279 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1280 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1281 case IMA_Instance:
1282 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1283
1284 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1285 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1286 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1287 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1288
1289 case IMA_Mixed:
1290 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1291 case IMA_Unresolved:
1292 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1293
1294 case IMA_Static:
1295 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1296 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1297 if (TemplateArgs)
1298 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1299 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1300
1301 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1302 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1303 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1304 return ExprError();
1305 }
1306
1307 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1308 return ExprError();
1309}
1310
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001311/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1312/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1313/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1314/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001315ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001316Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001317 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001319 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001320 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001322 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001323 return ExprError();
1324
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001325 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001326 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1327
1328 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1329 return ExprError();
1330
1331 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001332 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1333 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001334 return ExprError();
1335 }
1336
1337 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1338}
1339
1340/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1341/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1342/// additional lookup.
1343///
1344/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1345/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1346///
1347/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001348ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001349Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001350 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001352 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001353
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1355 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1356 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1357 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1358 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1359
1360 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1361 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1362 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001363 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001364
1365 bool LookForIvars;
1366 if (Lookup.empty())
1367 LookForIvars = true;
1368 else if (IsClassMethod)
1369 LookForIvars = false;
1370 else
1371 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1372 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001373 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001374 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001375 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1377 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1378 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1379 if (IsClassMethod)
1380 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1381 << IV->getDeclName());
1382
1383 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1384 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1385 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1386 return ExprError();
1387
1388 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1389 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1390 return ExprError();
1391
1392 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1393 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1394 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1395 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1396
1397 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1398 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1399 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1400 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001401 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001402 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001403 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001404 SelfName, false, false);
1405 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1406 return Owned(new (Context)
1407 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1408 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1409 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001410 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001411 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001412 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001413 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1414 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1415 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1416 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1417 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1418 }
1419 }
1420
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001421 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1422 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1423 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1424 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1425 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1426 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1427 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1428 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1429 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1430 }
1431 }
1432 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001433 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1434 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001435}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001436
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001437/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1438///
1439/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1440///
1441/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1442/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1443/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1444/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1445///
1446/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1447/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1448/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1449/// the class declaring the member.
1450///
1451/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1452/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1453/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001454bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001455Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1456 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001457 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001458 NamedDecl *Member) {
1459 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1460 if (!RD)
1461 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001462
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001463 QualType DestRecordType;
1464 QualType DestType;
1465 QualType FromRecordType;
1466 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1467 bool PointerConversions = false;
1468 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1469 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001470
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001471 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1472 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1473 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1474 PointerConversions = true;
1475 } else {
1476 DestType = DestRecordType;
1477 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001478 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001479 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1480 if (Method->isStatic())
1481 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001482
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001483 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1484 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001485
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001486 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1487 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1488 PointerConversions = true;
1489 } else {
1490 FromRecordType = FromType;
1491 DestType = DestRecordType;
1492 }
1493 } else {
1494 // No conversion necessary.
1495 return false;
1496 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001497
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1499 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001500
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001501 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1502 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1503 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001504
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001505 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1506 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1507
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001508 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001509
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001511 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 // class name.
1513 //
1514 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1515 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1516 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1517 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1518 //
1519 // class Base { public: int x; };
1520 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1521 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1522 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1523 //
1524 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1525 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1526 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1527 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001528 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001529 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1530 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1531 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1532
1533 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1534
1535 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1536 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1537 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1538 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001539 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001540 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001541 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001542 return true;
1543
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001544 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001545 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001546 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1547 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548
1549 FromType = QType;
1550 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1551
1552 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1553 // we're done.
1554 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1555 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001556 }
1557 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001558
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001559 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001560
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001561 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1562 // down to the using declaration's type.
1563 //
1564 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1565 // class ever has member declarations.
1566 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1567 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1568 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1569 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1570
1571 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1572 // conversion is non-trivial.
1573 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1574 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001575 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001576 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001577 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001578 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001579
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001580 QualType UType = URecordType;
1581 if (PointerConversions)
1582 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001583 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001584 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001585 FromType = UType;
1586 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1587 }
1588
1589 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1590 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1591 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001592 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001593
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001594 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001595 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1596 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001597 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001598 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001599
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001600 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001601 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001602 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001603}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001604
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001605/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001606static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001607 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001608 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001609 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1610 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001611 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1612 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1613 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001614 if (SS.isSet()) {
1615 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1616 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001618
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001619 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001620 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1621 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001622}
1623
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001624/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1625/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1626/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1627/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001628ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001629Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1630 LookupResult &R,
1631 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1632 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001633 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1634
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001635 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001636
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001637 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1638 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001639 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001640 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001641 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001642 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001643 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001644
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001645 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1646 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001647 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1648 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001649 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1650 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001651 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1652 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1653 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1654 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001655 }
1656
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001657 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001658 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1659 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001660 SS,
1661 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1662 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001663}
1664
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001665bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001666 const LookupResult &R,
1667 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001668 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1669 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1670 return false;
1671
1672 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001673 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674 return false;
1675
1676 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001677 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001678 return false;
1679
1680 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1681 // normal lookup:
1682 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1683 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1684
1685 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1686 // -- a declaration of a class member
1687 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1688 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001689 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001690 return false;
1691
1692 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1693 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1694 // using-declaration
1695 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1696 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1697 // turn off ADL anyway).
1698 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1699 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1700 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1701 return false;
1702
1703 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1704 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1705 // template
1706 // And also for builtin functions.
1707 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1708 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1709
1710 // But also builtin functions.
1711 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1712 return false;
1713 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1714 return false;
1715 }
1716
1717 return true;
1718}
1719
1720
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001721/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1722/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1723/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1724/// will in fact be used.
1725static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1726 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1727 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1728 return true;
1729 }
1730
1731 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1732 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1733 return true;
1734 }
1735
1736 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1737 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1738 return true;
1739 }
1740
1741 return false;
1742}
1743
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001744ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001745Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001746 LookupResult &R,
1747 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001748 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1749 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001750 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001751 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1752 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001753
1754 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1755 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1756 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001757 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1758 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001759 return ExprError();
1760
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001761 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1762 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1763 // we've picked a target.
1764 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1765
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001766 bool Dependent
1767 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001768 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001769 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001770 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001771 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001772 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1773 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001774
1775 return Owned(ULE);
1776}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001777
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001778
1779/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001780ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001781Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001782 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1783 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001784 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001785 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1786 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001787
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001788 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001789 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1790 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001791
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001792 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1793 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1794 // a template argument list.
1795 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1796 << Template << SS.getRange();
1797 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1798 return ExprError();
1799 }
1800
1801 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1802 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1803 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001804 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001805 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001806 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001807 return ExprError();
1808 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001809
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001810 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1811 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1812 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1813 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001814 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001815 return ExprError();
1816
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001817 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1818 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001819 return ExprError();
1820
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001821 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1822 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1823 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1824 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001825 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001826 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1827 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1828 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001829 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001830 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001831 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1832 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1833 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1834 return ExprError();
1835 }
1836
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001837 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001838 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1840 return ExprError();
1841 }
1842
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001843 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001844 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001845 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001846 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001847 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001848 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1849 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001850 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001851
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001852 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001853 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001854 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1855 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001856 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001857 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1858 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1859 Expr *E = new (Context)
1860 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1861 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001862
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001863 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001864 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001865 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001866 SourceLocation(),
1867 Owned(E));
1868 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001869 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001870 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1871 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1872 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001873 }
1874 }
1875 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001876 }
1877 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1878 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001879
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001880 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1881 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001882}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001883
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001884ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001886 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001887
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001888 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001889 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001890 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1891 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1892 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001893 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001894
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001895 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1896 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001897
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001898 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001899 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1900 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001901 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001902 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001903 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001904 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001905
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001906 QualType ResTy;
1907 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1908 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1909 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001910 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001911
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001912 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001913 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001914 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1915 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001916 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001917}
1918
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001919ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001920 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001921 bool Invalid = false;
1922 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1923 if (Invalid)
1924 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001925
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001926 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1927 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001928 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001929 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001930
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001931 QualType Ty;
1932 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1933 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1934 else if (Literal.isWide())
1935 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001936 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1937 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001938 else
1939 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001940
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001941 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1942 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001943 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001944}
1945
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001946ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001947 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001948 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1949 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001950 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001951 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001952 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001953 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001954 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001955
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001956 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001957 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1958 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001959 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001960
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001962 bool Invalid = false;
1963 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1964 if (Invalid)
1965 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001967 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001968 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001969 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001970 return ExprError();
1971
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001973
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001974 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001975 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001976 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001977 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001978 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001979 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001980 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001981 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001982
1983 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1984
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001985 using llvm::APFloat;
1986 APFloat Val(Format);
1987
1988 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001989
1990 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1991 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1992 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1993 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001994 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001995 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001996 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001997 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001998 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1999 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002000 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002001 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2002 }
2003
2004 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2005 << Ty
2006 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2007 }
2008
2009 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002010 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002011
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002012 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002013 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002014 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002015 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002016
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002017 // long long is a C99 feature.
2018 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002019 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002020 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2021
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002022 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002023 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002024
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002025 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2026 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2027 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002028 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2029 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002030 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002031 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002032 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2033 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002034
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002035 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2036 // be an unsigned int.
2037 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2038
2039 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002040 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002041 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2042 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002043 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002044
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002045 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2046 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2047 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2048 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002049 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002050 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002051 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002052 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002053 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002054 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002055
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002056 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002058 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002059
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002060 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2061 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2062 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2063 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002064 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002065 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002066 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002067 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002068 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002069 }
2070
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002071 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002072 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002074
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002075 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2076 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2077 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2078 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002079 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002080 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002081 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002082 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002083 }
2084 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002085
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2087 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002088 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002090 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002092 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002093
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002094 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2095 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002096 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002097 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002098 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002099
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002100 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2101 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002102 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002103 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002104
2105 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002106}
2107
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002108ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002109 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002110 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002111 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002112}
2113
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002114/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002115/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002116bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002117 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2118 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2119 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002120 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2121 return false;
2122
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002123 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2124 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2125 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2126 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2127 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2128 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2129
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002130 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002131 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002132 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002133 if (isSizeof)
2134 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2135 return false;
2136 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002137
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002138 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002139 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2141 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002142 return false;
2143 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002144
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002145 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002146 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2147 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002148 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002150 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002151 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002152 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002153 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2154 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002155 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002156
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002157 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2159 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2160 return true;
2161 }
2162
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002163 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002164}
2165
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002166bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2167 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2168 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002169
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002170 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002171 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2172 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002173
2174 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2175 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2176 return false;
2177
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002178 if (E->getBitField()) {
2179 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2180 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002181 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002182
2183 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2184 // bit-field.
2185 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002186 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002187 return false;
2188
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002189 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2190}
2191
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002192/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002193ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002194Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002195 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002196 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002197 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002198 return ExprError();
2199
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002201
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002202 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2203 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2204 return ExprError();
2205
2206 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002207 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002208 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2209 R.getEnd()));
2210}
2211
2212/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2213/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002214ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002215Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002216 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2217 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2218 bool isInvalid = false;
2219 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2220 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2221 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2222 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002223 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2225 isInvalid = true;
2226 } else {
2227 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2228 }
2229
2230 if (isInvalid)
2231 return ExprError();
2232
2233 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2234 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2235 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2236 R.getEnd()));
2237}
2238
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002239/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2240/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2241/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002242ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002243Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2244 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002245 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002246 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002247
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002248 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002249 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002250 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002251 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002252 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002253
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002254 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002255 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002256 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2257
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002258 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002259}
2260
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002261QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002262 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2263 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002264
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002265 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002266 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002267 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002268
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002269 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2270 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2271 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002272
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002273 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002274 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2275 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002276 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002277}
2278
2279
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002280
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002281ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002282Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002283 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002284 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002285 switch (Kind) {
2286 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002287 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2288 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002289 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002290
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002291 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002292}
2293
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002294ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002295Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2296 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002297 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002298 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002299 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2300 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002301
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002302 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002304 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002305 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002306 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2307 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2308 }
2309
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002311 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002312 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2313 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2314 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002315 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002316 }
2317
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002318 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002319}
2320
2321
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002322ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002323Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2324 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2325 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2326 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002327
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002328 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002329 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2330 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2331 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002332
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002333 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002334
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002335 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002336 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002337 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002338 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002339 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2340 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002341 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2342 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2343 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2344 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002345 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002346 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2347 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002348 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002349 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002350 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002351 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2352 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002353 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002354 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002355 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002356 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2357 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2358 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002359 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002360 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002361 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2362 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2363 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2364 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002365 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002366 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002367 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002368
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002369 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2370 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002371 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2372 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002373 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002374 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2375 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2376 // force the promotion here.
2377 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2378 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002379 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002380 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002381 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2382
2383 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2384 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002385 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002386 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2387 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2388 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2389 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002390 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002391 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002392 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2393
2394 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2395 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002396 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002397 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002398 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2399 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002400 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002401 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002402 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002403 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2404 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002405
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002406 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002407 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2408 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002409 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2410
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002411 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002412 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2413 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002414 // incomplete types are not object types.
2415 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2416 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2417 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2418 return ExprError();
2419 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002420
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002421 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2422 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2423 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2424 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2425 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002426 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002427 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2428 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002429 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002430
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002431 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002432 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002433 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2434 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2435 return ExprError();
2436 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002437
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002438 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002439 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002440}
2441
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002442QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002443CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002444 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002445 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002446 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2447 // see FIXME there.
2448 //
2449 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2450 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002451 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002452
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002453 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002454 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002455
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002456 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002457 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2458 // to be selected.
2459 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002460
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002461 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2462 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002463 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002464
2465 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2466 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002467 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002468 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2469 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002470 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002471 do
2472 compStr++;
2473 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002474 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002475 do
2476 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002477 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002478 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002479
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002480 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002481 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2482 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002483 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002484 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002485 return QualType();
2486 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002487
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002488 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2489 // operates on.
2490 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002491 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002492
2493 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002494 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002495
2496 while (*compStr) {
2497 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2498 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2499 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2500 return QualType();
2501 }
2502 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002503 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002504
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002505 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002506 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002507 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002508 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002509 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002510 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002511 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002512 if (HexSwizzle)
2513 CompSize--;
2514
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002515 if (CompSize == 1)
2516 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002517
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002518 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002519 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002520 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2521 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2522 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2523 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002524 }
2525 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002526}
2527
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002528static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002529 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002530 const Selector &Sel,
2531 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002532
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002533 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002534 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002535 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002536 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002537
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002538 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2539 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002540 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002541 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002542 return D;
2543 }
2544 return 0;
2545}
2546
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002547static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002548 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002549 const Selector &Sel,
2550 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002551 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2552 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002553 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002554 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002555 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002556 GDecl = PD;
2557 break;
2558 }
2559 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002560 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002561 GDecl = OMD;
2562 break;
2563 }
2564 }
2565 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002566 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002567 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2568 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002569 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002570 if (GDecl)
2571 return GDecl;
2572 }
2573 }
2574 return GDecl;
2575}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002576
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002577ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002578Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002579 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002580 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2581 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002582 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002583 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002584 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2585 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2586 //
2587 // T* t;
2588 // t.f;
2589 //
2590 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2591 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2592 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2593 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002594 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002595 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2596 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002597 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002598 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002599 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002600 return ExprError();
2601 }
2602 }
2603
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002604 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2605 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002606 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002607
2608 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2609 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002610 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002611 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002612 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002613 SS.getRange(),
2614 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002615 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616}
2617
2618/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2619/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2620/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2621static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2622 Expr *BaseExpr,
2623 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002624 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002626 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2627 // diagnostics.
2628 if (!BaseExpr)
2629 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002631 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2632 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633}
2634
2635// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2636// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2637// type. The restriction here is:
2638//
2639// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2640// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2641// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2642//
2643// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2644// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2645// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2646// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2647bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2648 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002649 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002650 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002651 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2652 if (!BaseRT) {
2653 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2654 // dependent.
2655 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2656 return false;
2657 }
2658 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002659
2660 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002661 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2662 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002663 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002664 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002665
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002667 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2668 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2669 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002671 if (!DC->isRecord())
2672 continue;
2673
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002674 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002675 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002676
2677 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2678 return false;
2679 }
2680
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002681 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002682 return true;
2683}
2684
2685static bool
2686LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2687 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002688 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2689 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002690 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2691 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002692 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002693 << BaseRange))
2694 return true;
2695
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002696 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2697 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2698 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2699
2700 bool MOUS;
2701 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2702 return false;
2703 }
2704
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002705 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2706 if (SS.isSet()) {
2707 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2708 // nested-name-specifier.
2709 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2710
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002711 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002712 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2713 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2714 return true;
2715 }
2716
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002717 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002719 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2720 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2721 << DC << SS.getRange();
2722 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002723 }
2724 }
2725
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2727 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002729 if (!R.empty())
2730 return false;
2731
2732 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2733 // for typos.
2734 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002735 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002736 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002737 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2738 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2739 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002740 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2741 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002742 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2743 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2744 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002745 return false;
2746 } else {
2747 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002748 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002749 }
2750
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002751 return false;
2752}
2753
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002754ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002755Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002757 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002758 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002759 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002761 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2762 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002763 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2765 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002766 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002767
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002768 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002770 // Implicit member accesses.
2771 if (!Base) {
2772 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2773 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2774 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2775 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002776 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002777 return ExprError();
2778
2779 // Explicit member accesses.
2780 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002781 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002782 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002783 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002784
2785 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2786 Owned(Base);
2787 return ExprError();
2788 }
2789
2790 if (Result.get())
2791 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002792
2793 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2794 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795 }
2796
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002797 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002798 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2799 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002800}
2801
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002802ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002803Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002804 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2805 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002806 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002807 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002808 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2809 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002810 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002811 if (IsArrow) {
2812 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2813 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2814 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002815 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002817 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002818 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2819 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2820 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821
2822 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002823 return ExprError();
2824
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825 if (R.empty()) {
2826 // Rederive where we looked up.
2827 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2828 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2829 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002830
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002832 << MemberName << DC
2833 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002834 return ExprError();
2835 }
2836
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002837 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2838 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2839 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2840 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2841 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2842 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2843 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2844 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2845 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2846 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002847 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002848 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002849 return ExprError();
2850
2851 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2852 // result.
2853 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002854 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002855 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002856 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002857 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002859 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2860 // pick a member.
2861 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2862
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2864 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2865 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002866 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2867 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002869 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002870 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871
2872 return Owned(MemExpr);
2873 }
2874
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002875 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002876 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2878
2879 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2880
2881 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2882 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2883 // error cases.
2884 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2885 return ExprError();
2886
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002887 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2888 if (!BaseExpr) {
2889 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002890 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002891 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002892
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002893 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2894 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2895 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2896 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002897 }
2898
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002899 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2900 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2901 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2902 // explicitly qualified.
2903 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2904 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2905 }
2906
2907 // Check the use of this member.
2908 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2909 Owned(BaseExpr);
2910 return ExprError();
2911 }
2912
2913 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2914 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2915 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002916 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2917 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002918 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2919 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2920
2921 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2922 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2923 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2924 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2925 else {
2926 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2927 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2928 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2929
2930 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2931 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2932
2933 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2934 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2935 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2936 }
2937
2938 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002939 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940 return ExprError();
2941 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002942 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2943 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002944 }
2945
2946 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2947 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2948 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002949 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002950 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2951 }
2952
2953 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2954 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2955 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002956 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002957 MemberFn->getType()));
2958 }
2959
2960 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2961 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2962 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002963 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2964 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002965 }
2966
2967 Owned(BaseExpr);
2968
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002969 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002970 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002971 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002972 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2973 else
2974 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2975 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002976
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002977 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2978 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002979 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002980 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981}
2982
2983/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2984/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2985/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2986/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2987/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2988/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2989/// an ordinary member expression.
2990///
2991/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2992/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002993ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002994Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002995 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002996 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002997 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002998 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002999
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003000 // Perform default conversions.
3001 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003002
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003003 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003004 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3005
3006 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3007 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003008
3009 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003010 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003011 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3012 // call, and continue on.
3013 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3014 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3015 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3016 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3017 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003018 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3019 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003020 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3021 ->isRecordType()))) {
3022 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3023 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3024 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003025 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003026
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003027 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003028 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003029 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003030 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003031 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003032
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003033 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3034 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3035 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3036 }
3037 }
3038 }
3039
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003040 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3041 // use that.
3042 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003043 if (IsArrow) {
3044 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3045 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3046 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003047 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003048 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003049 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3050 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003051 }
3052 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003053 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3054 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3055 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3056 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003057 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003058 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003059 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003060
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003061 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3062 // use that.
3063 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3064 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3065 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3066 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3067 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003068 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003069 }
3070 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003071
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003072 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003073
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003074 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003075 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003076 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3077 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3078 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3079 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3080 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3081 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3082 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3083 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3084 // Check the use of this method.
3085 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3086 return ExprError();
3087 }
3088 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3089 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3090 Selector SetterSel =
3091 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3092 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3093 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3094 if (!Setter) {
3095 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3096 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003097 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003098 }
3099 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3100 if (!Setter)
3101 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003102
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003103 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3104 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003105
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003106 if (Getter || Setter) {
3107 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003108
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003109 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003110 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003111 else
3112 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3113 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3114 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003115 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003116 PType,
3117 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3118 }
3119 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3120 << MemberName << BaseType);
3121 }
3122 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003123
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003124 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3125 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3126 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003127 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003128 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003129
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003130 if (IsArrow) {
3131 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003132 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003133 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3134 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003135 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3136 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3137 // struct MyRecord foo;
3138 // foo->bar
3139 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3140 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3141 // by now.
3142 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3143 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003144 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003145 IsArrow = false;
3146 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003147 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3148 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3149 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003150 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003151 } else {
3152 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3153 // type *foo;
3154 // foo.bar
3155 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3156 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3157 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3158 // the appropriate pointer type
3159 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3160 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3161 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3162 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3163 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003164 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003165 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3166 IsArrow = true;
3167 }
3168 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003169 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003170
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003171 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003172 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003173 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003174 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003175 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003176 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003177 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003178
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003179 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3180 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003181 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003182 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003183 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003184 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3185 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3186 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3187 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003188 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3189
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003190 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003192
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003193 if (!IV) {
3194 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3195 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3196 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003197 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003198 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003199 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003200 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3201 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003202 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3203 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003204 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003205 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003206 } else {
3207 Res.clear();
3208 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003209 }
3210 }
3211
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003212 if (IV) {
3213 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3214 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3215 // error cases.
3216 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3217 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003218
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003219 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3220 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3221 return ExprError();
3222 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3223 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3224 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3225 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3226 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3227 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3228 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3229 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3230 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3231 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3232 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3233 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003234 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003235 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003236 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3237 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003238 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003239 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3240 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003241
3242 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3243 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003244 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003245 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003246 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003247 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3248 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003249 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003250 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003251 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252
3253 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3254 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003255 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003256 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003257 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003258 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003259 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003260 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003261 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003262 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003263 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3264 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003265 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003266 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003267
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003268 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003269 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003270 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3271 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3272 // Check the use of this declaration
3273 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3274 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003275
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003276 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3277 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3278 }
3279 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3280 // Check the use of this method.
3281 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3282 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003283
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003284 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003285 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003286 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3287 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003288 }
3289 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003290
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003291 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003292 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003293 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003294
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003295 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3296 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003297 if (!IsArrow)
3298 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3299 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003300 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003301
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003302 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003303 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003304 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3305 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003306 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003307 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003308 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003309
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003310 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003311 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003312 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003313 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3314 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003315 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003316 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003317 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003318 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003319
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003320 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3321 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3322
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003323 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003324}
3325
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003326/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3327/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3328/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3329/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3330/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3331///
3332/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3333/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3334/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3335/// only be called
3336/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3337/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3338/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003339ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003340 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3341 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003342 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003343 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003344 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003345 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3346 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3347 return ExprError();
3348
3349 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3350
3351 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003352 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003353 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3354 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003355 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003356
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003357 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003358 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3359
3360 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3361 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3362 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3363
3364 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003365 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003366 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3367 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003368
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003369 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3370 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003371 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003372 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3373 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003374 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003376 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003377 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3378 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003379
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003380 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3381 Owned(Base);
3382 return ExprError();
3383 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003384
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003385 if (Result.get()) {
3386 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3387 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3388 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3389 // call now.
3390 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3391 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003392 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003393
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003394 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003395 }
3396
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003397 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003398 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3399 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003400 }
3401
3402 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003403}
3404
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003405ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003406 FunctionDecl *FD,
3407 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3408 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003409 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003410 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3411 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003412 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003413 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003414 return ExprError();
3415 }
3416
3417 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3418 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003419
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003420 // Instantiate the expression.
3421 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3422 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003423
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003424 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3425 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3426 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3427 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003429 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3430 if (Result.isInvalid())
3431 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003432
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003433 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3434 InitializedEntity Entity
3435 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3436 InitializationKind Kind
3437 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3438 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3439 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003440
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003441 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3442 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3443 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3444 if (Result.isInvalid())
3445 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003446
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003447 // Build the default argument expression.
3448 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3449 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003450 }
3451
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003452 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3453 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3454 // be properly destroyed.
3455 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3456 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003457 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3458 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3459 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3460 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3461 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3462 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003463
3464 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003465 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3466 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003467 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003468 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003469}
3470
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003471/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3472/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3473/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3474/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3475/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3476/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003477bool
3478Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003479 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003480 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003481 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3482 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003483 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3485 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003486 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003487
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003488 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3489 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3490 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3491 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3492 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003493 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003494 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003495 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003496 }
3497
3498 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3499 // them.
3500 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3501 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3502 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3503 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003504 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003505 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003506 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3507 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3508 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003509 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003510 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003511 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003512 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003513 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003514 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003515 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3516 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3517 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3518 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3519 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003520 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003521 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003522 if (Invalid)
3523 return true;
3524 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3525 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3526 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003527
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003528 return false;
3529}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003530
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003531bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3532 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3533 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3534 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3535 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3536 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003537 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003538 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3539 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3540 bool Invalid = false;
3541 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3542 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3543 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3544 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003546 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003547 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003548
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003550 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3551 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003552
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003553 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3554 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003555 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003556 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003557 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003558
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003559 // Pass the argument
3560 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3561 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3562 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003563
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003564
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003565 InitializedEntity Entity =
3566 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3567 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003568 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003569 SourceLocation(),
3570 Owned(Arg));
3571 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3572 return true;
3573
3574 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003575 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003576 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003577
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003578 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003579 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003580 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3581 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003582
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003583 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003584 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003585 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003587
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003588 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003589 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003590 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003591 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003592 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003593 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003594 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003595 }
3596 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003597 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003598}
3599
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003600/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003601/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3602/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003603ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003604Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003605 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003606 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003607
3608 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003609 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003610 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3611 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003612
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003613 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003614
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003615 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003616 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3617 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3618 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3619 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3620 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003621 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003622 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3623 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003624
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003625 NumArgs = 0;
3626 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003627
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003628 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3629 RParenLoc));
3630 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003631
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003632 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003633 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003634 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3635 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003636 bool Dependent = false;
3637 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3638 Dependent = true;
3639 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3640 Dependent = true;
3641
3642 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003643 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003644 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3645
3646 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3647 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3648 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003649 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003650
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003651 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3652
3653 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3654 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3655 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3656 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3657 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3658 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3659 // method template.
3660 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003661 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3662 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003663 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003664
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003665 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003666 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003667 }
3668
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003669 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003670 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003671 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003672 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003673 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003674 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003675 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003676
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003677 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003678 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003679 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3680 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003681 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3682 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003683 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003684
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003685 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3686 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3687 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3688 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003689
3690 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3691 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003692 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003693 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003694
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003695 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003696 RParenLoc))
3697 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003698
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003699 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003700 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003701 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003702 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3703 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003704 }
3705 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003706 }
3707
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003708 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003709 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003710 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003711
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003712 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003713 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3714 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003715 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003716 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003717 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003718
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003719 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3720 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3721 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3722
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003723 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3724}
3725
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003726/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3727/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003728/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3729/// block-pointer type.
3730///
3731/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003732ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003733Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3734 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3735 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3736 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3737 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3738
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003739 // Promote the function operand.
3740 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3741
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003742 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3743 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003744 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3745 Args, NumArgs,
3746 Context.BoolTy,
3747 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003748
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003749 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3750 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3751 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3752 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003753 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003754 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003755 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3756 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003757 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003758 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003759 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003760 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003761 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003762 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003763 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3764 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3765
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003766 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003767 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003768 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003769 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003770 return ExprError();
3771
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003772 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003773 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003774
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003775 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003776 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003777 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003778 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003779 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003780 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003781
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003782 if (FDecl) {
3783 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3784 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3785 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003786 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003787 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003788 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003789 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3790 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3791 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3792 }
3793 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003794 }
3795
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003796 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003797 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3798 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3799 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003800 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3801 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003802 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3803 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003804 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003805 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003806 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003807 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003808
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003809 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3810 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003811 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3812 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003813
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003814 // Check for sentinels
3815 if (NDecl)
3816 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003817
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003818 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003819 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003820 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003821 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003822
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003823 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003824 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003825 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003826 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003827 return ExprError();
3828 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003829
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003830 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003831}
3832
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003833ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003834Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003835 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003836 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003837 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003838 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003839
3840 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3841 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3842 if (!TInfo)
3843 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3844
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003845 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003846}
3847
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003848ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003849Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003850 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003851 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003852
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003853 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003854 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003855 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3856 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003857 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3858 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003859 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003860 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003861 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003862 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003863
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003864 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003865 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003866 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003867 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003868 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003869 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003870 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003871 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003872 &literalType);
3873 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003874 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003875 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003876
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003877 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003878 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003879 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003880 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003881 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003882
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003883 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003884 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003885}
3886
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003887ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003888Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003889 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3890 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003891 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003892
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003893 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003894 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003895
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003896 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3897 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003898 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003899 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003900}
3901
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003902static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003903 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003904 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003905 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003906
3907 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3908 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003909 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003910 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3911 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003912 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003913 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003914 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003915
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003916 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3917 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003918 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003919 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003920 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003921 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003922 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003923 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003924
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3926 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003927 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003928 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003929 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003930 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003931
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003932 // FIXME: Assert here.
3933 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003934 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003935}
3936
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003937/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003938bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003939 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003940 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003941 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003942 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003943 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3944 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003945
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003946 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003947
3948 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3949 // type needs to be scalar.
3950 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3951 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003952 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003953 return false;
3954 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003955
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003956 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3957 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3958 return true;
3959
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003960 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003961 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003962 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3963 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003964 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003965 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3966 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003967 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003968 return false;
3969 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003971 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003972 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003973 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003974 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003975 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003976 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003977 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003978 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003979 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3980 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3981 break;
3982 }
3983 }
3984 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3985 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3986 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003987 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003988 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003989 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003990
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003991 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3992 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3993 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3994 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003995
3996 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003997 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003998 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3999 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004000 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004001 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004002
4003 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004004 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004005
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004006 if (castType->isVectorType())
4007 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4008 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4009 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4010
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004011 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4012 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004013
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004014 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004015 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004016 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004017 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004018 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4019 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4020 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4021 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004022 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004023 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4024 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4025 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004026 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004027
4028 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004029
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004030 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004031 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4032
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004033 return false;
4034}
4035
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004036bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004037 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004038 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004039
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004040 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004041 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004042 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004043 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004044 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004045 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004046 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004047 } else
4048 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004049 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004050 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004051
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004052 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004053 return false;
4054}
4055
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004056bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004057 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004058 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004059
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004060 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004061
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004062 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4063 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004064 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4065 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4066 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4067 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004068 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004069 return false;
4070 }
4071
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004072 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004073 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4074 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004075 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4076 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4077 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4078 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004079
4080 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4081 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4082 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004083
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004084 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004085 return false;
4086}
4087
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004088ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004089Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004090 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4091 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004092 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004093
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004094 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4095 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4096 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004097 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004098
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004099 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4100 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004101 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004102 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004103
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004104 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004105}
4106
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004107ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004108Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004109 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004110 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004111 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004112 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004113 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004114 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004115
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004116 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004117 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004118 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4119 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004120}
4121
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004122/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4123/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004124ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004125Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004126 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4127 if (!E)
4128 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004129
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004130 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004131
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004132 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004133 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4134 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004135
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004136 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4137
4138 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004139}
4140
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004141ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004142Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004143 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004144 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004145 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004146 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004147 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004148
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004149 // Check for an altivec literal,
4150 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004151 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4152 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4153 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4154 return ExprError();
4155 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004156 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4157 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4158 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4159 }
4160 else
4161 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4162 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004163
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004164 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4165 // then handle it as such.
4166 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004167 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4168 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4169 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4170
4171 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4172 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004173 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4174 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004175 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4176 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004177 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004178 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004179 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004180 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004181 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004182 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4183 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004184 }
4185}
4186
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004187ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004188 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004189 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004190 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004191 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4192 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004193 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4194 Expr *expr;
4195 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4196 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4197 else
4198 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004199 return Owned(expr);
4200}
4201
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004202/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4203/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004204/// C99 6.5.15
4205QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4206 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004207 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4208 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4209 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4210
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004211 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4212 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4213 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4214 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4215 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4216 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004217
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004218 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004219 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4220 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4221 << CondTy;
4222 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004223 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004224
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004225 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004226 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4227 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004228
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004229 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4230 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004231 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4232 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4233 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004234 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004235
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004236 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4237 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004238 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4239 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004240 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004241 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004242 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004243 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004244 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004245 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004246
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004247 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004248 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004249 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4250 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4251 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4252 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4253 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4254 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4255 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004256 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4257 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004258 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004259 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004260 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4261 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004262 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004263 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004264 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004265 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004266 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004267 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004268 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004269 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004270 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004271 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004272 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004273
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004274 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4275 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4276 QuestionLoc);
4277 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4278 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004279
4280
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004281 // Handle block pointer types.
4282 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4283 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4284 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4285 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004286 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4287 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004288 return destType;
4289 }
4290 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004291 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004292 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004293 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004294 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4295 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4296 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004297 return LHSTy;
4298 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004299 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004300 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4301 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004302
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004303 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4304 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004305 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004306 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004307 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4308 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4309 // to get a consistent AST.
4310 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004311 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4312 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004313 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004314 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004315 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004316 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4317 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004318 return LHSTy;
4319 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004320
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004321 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4322 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4323 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004324 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4325 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004326
4327 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4328 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4329 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004330 QualType destPointee
4331 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004332 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004333 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004334 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004335 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004336 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004337 return destType;
4338 }
4339 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004340 QualType destPointee
4341 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004342 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004343 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004344 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004345 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004346 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004347 return destType;
4348 }
4349
4350 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4351 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4352 return LHSTy;
4353 }
4354 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4355 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4356 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4357 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4358 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4359 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4360 // to get a consistent AST.
4361 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004362 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4363 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004364 return incompatTy;
4365 }
4366 // The pointer types are compatible.
4367 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4368 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4369 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4370 // type.
4371 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4372 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004373 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4374 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004375 return LHSTy;
4376 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004377
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004378 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4379 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4380 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4381 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004382 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004383 return RHSTy;
4384 }
4385 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4386 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4387 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004388 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004389 return LHSTy;
4390 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004391
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004392 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004393 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4394 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004395 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004396}
4397
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004398/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4399/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4400QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4401 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4402 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4403 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004404
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004405 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4406 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4407 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4408 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4409 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004410 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004411 return LHSTy;
4412 }
4413 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4414 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004415 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004416 return RHSTy;
4417 }
4418 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4419 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4420 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004421 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004422 return LHSTy;
4423 }
4424 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4425 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004426 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004427 return RHSTy;
4428 }
4429 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4430 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4431 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004432 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004433 return LHSTy;
4434 }
4435 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4436 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004437 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004438 return RHSTy;
4439 }
4440 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4441 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004442
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004443 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4444 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4445 return LHSTy;
4446 }
4447 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4448 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4449 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004450
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004451 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4452 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4453 // type. This allows
4454 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4455 // where B is a subclass of A.
4456 //
4457 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4458 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4459 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4460 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004461
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004462 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4463 // It could return the composite type.
4464 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4465 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4466 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4467 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4468 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4469 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4470 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4471 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4472 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4473 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4474 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4475 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4476 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4477 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004478 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004479 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4480 ;
4481 else {
4482 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4483 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4484 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4485 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004486 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4487 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004488 return incompatTy;
4489 }
4490 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004491 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4492 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004493 return compositeType;
4494 }
4495 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4496 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4497 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4498 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4499 QualType destPointee
4500 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4501 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4502 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004503 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004504 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004505 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004506 return destType;
4507 }
4508 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4509 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4510 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4511 QualType destPointee
4512 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4513 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4514 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004515 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004516 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004517 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004518 return destType;
4519 }
4520 return QualType();
4521}
4522
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004523/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004524/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004525ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004526 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004527 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4528 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004529 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4530 // was the condition.
4531 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004532 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4533 if (isLHSNull) {
4534 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4535 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004536
4537 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004538 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004539 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004540 return ExprError();
4541
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004542 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004543 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4544 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4545 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004546}
4547
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004548// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004549// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004550// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4551// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4552// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004553Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004554Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004555 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004556
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004557 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4558 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4559 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4560 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4561 return Compatible;
4562 }
4563
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004564 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004565 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4566 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004567
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004568 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004569 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4570 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004571
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004572 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004573
4574 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4575 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4576 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004577 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004578 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004579 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004580
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004581 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4582 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004583 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004584 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004585 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004586 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004587
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004588 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004589 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4590 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004591 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004592
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004593 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004594 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004595 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004596
4597 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004598 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4599 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004600 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004601 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004602 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004603 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4604 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4605 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4606 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4607 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4608 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004609 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004610 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004611 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004612 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004613
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004614 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004615 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004616 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004617 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004618
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004619 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4620 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4621 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4622 // warning can be disabled.
4623 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4624 return ConvTy;
4625 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4626 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004627
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004628 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4629 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4630 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4631 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4632 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4633 do {
4634 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4635 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004636
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004637 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4638 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4639 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004640
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004641 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004642 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004643 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004644
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004645 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004646 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004647 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004648 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004649}
4650
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004651/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4652/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4653/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4654// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004655Sema::AssignConvertType
4656Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004657 QualType rhsType) {
4658 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004659
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004660 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004661 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4662 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004663
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004664 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4665 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4666 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004667
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004668 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004669
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004670 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004671 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004672 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004673
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004674 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4675 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4676 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4677 }
4678 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004679 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004680 return ConvTy;
4681}
4682
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004683/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4684/// for assignment compatibility.
4685Sema::AssignConvertType
4686Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004687 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4688 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004689 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4690 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004691 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004692 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004693 }
4694 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4695 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004696 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4697 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004698 return IncompatiblePointer;
4699 return Compatible;
4700 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004701 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004702 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004703 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004704 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4705 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4706 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4707 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4708 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4709 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004710
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004711 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4712 return Compatible;
4713 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4714 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004715 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004716}
4717
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004718/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4719/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004720/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4721///
4722/// int a, *pint;
4723/// short *pshort;
4724/// struct foo *pfoo;
4725///
4726/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4727/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4728/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4729/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4730///
4731/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004732/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004733///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004734Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004735Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004736 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4737 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004738 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4739 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004740
4741 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004742 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004743
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004744 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4745 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4746 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4747 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4748 return Compatible;
4749 }
4750
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004751 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4752 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4753 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4754 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4755 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4756 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4757 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004758 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004759 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004760 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004761 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004762 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004763 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4764 // to the same ExtVector type.
4765 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4766 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4767 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004768 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004769 return Compatible;
4770 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004771
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004772 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004773 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4774 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4775 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4776 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4777 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4778 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004779 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004780
4781 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4782 // vector type and vice versa
4783 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4784 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004785 }
4786 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004787 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004788
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004789 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4790 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004791 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004792
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004793 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004794 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004795 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004796
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004797 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004798 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004799
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004800 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004801 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004802 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4803 return Compatible;
4804 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004805 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004806 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4807 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004808 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004809
4810 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004811 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004812 return Compatible;
4813 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004814 return Incompatible;
4815 }
4816
4817 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4818 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004819 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004820
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004821 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004822 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004823 return Compatible;
4824
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004825 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4826 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004827
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004828 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004829 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004830 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004831 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004832 return Incompatible;
4833 }
4834
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004835 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4836 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4837 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004838
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004839 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004840 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004841 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4842 return Compatible;
4843 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004844 }
4845 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004846 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004847 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004848 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004849 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4850 return Compatible;
4851 }
4852 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4853 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4854 return Compatible;
4855 return Incompatible;
4856 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004857 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004858 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004859 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4860 return Compatible;
4861
4862 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004863 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004864
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004865 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004866 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004867
4868 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004869 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004870 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004871 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004872 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004873 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4874 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4875 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4876 return Compatible;
4877
4878 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4879 return PointerToInt;
4880
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004881 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004882 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004883 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4884 return Compatible;
4885 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004886 }
4887 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004888 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004889 return Compatible;
4890 return Incompatible;
4891 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004892
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004893 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004894 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004895 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004896 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004897 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004898}
4899
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004900/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4901/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004902static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004903 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4904 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4905 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004906 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004907 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004908 SourceLocation());
4909 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4910 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4911
4912 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4913 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004914 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004915 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004916 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004917}
4918
4919Sema::AssignConvertType
4920Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4921 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4922
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004923 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004924 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4925 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004926 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004927 return Incompatible;
4928
4929 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4930 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4931 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4932 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004933 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4934 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004935 it != itend; ++it) {
4936 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4937 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4938 // 1) void pointer
4939 // 2) null pointer constant
4940 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004941 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004942 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004943 InitField = *it;
4944 break;
4945 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004946
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004947 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004948 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004949 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004950 InitField = *it;
4951 break;
4952 }
4953 }
4954
4955 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4956 == Compatible) {
4957 InitField = *it;
4958 break;
4959 }
4960 }
4961
4962 if (!InitField)
4963 return Incompatible;
4964
4965 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4966 return Compatible;
4967}
4968
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004969Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004970Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004971 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4972 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4973 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4974 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4975 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004976 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004977 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004978 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004979 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004980 }
4981
4982 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4983 // structures.
4984 }
4985
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004986 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4987 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004988 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4989 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004990 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004991 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004992 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004993 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004994 return Compatible;
4995 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004996
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004997 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004998 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004999 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005000 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005001 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005002 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005003 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005004 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005005
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005006 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5007 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005008
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005009 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5010 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005011 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5012 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5013 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5014 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005015 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005016 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005017 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005018 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005019}
5020
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005021QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005022 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005023 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005024 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005025 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005026}
5027
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005028QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005029 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005030 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005031 QualType lhsType =
5032 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5033 QualType rhsType =
5034 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005035
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005036 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005037 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005038 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005039
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005040 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5041 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005042 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005043 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005044 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005045 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005046 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005047 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005048 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005049 return lhsType;
5050 }
5051
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005052 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005053 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005054 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5055 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5056 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5057 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5058 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5059 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005060 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005061 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005062 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005063 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005064
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005065 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5066 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5067 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005068 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005069 return rhsType;
5070 }
5071
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005072 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5073 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5074 bool swapped = false;
5075 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5076 swapped = true;
5077 std::swap(rex, lex);
5078 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5079 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005080
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005081 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005082 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005083 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005084 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005085 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005086 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005087 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5088 return lhsType;
5089 }
5090 }
5091 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5092 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5093 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005094 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005095 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5096 return lhsType;
5097 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005098 }
5099 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005100
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005101 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005102 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005103 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005104 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005105 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005106}
5107
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005108QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5109 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005110 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005111 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005113 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005114
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005115 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5116 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5117 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005118
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005119 // Check for division by zero.
5120 if (isDiv &&
5121 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005122 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005123 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005124
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005125 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005126}
5127
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005128QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005129 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005130 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005131 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5132 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005133 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5134 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5135 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005136
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005137 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005138
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005139 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5140 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005141
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005142 // Check for remainder by zero.
5143 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005144 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5145 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005146
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005147 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005148}
5149
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005150QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005151 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005152 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5153 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5154 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5155 return compType;
5156 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005157
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005158 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005159
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005160 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005161 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5162 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5163 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005164 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005165 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005166
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005167 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5168 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005169 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005170 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5171
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005172 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005173
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005174 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005175 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005176
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005177 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5178 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5180 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005181 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005182 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005183 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005184
5185 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5186 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5187 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005188 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005189 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5190 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5191 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5192 return QualType();
5193 }
5194
5195 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5196 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5197 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005198 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005199 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005200 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005201 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005202 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5203 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005204 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5205 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005206 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005207 return QualType();
5208 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005209 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005210 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005211 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5212 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5213 return QualType();
5214 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005215
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005216 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005217 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5218 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5219 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5220 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5221 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005222 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005223 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5224 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005225 return PExp->getType();
5226 }
5227 }
5228
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005229 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005230}
5231
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005232// C99 6.5.6
5233QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005234 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5235 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5236 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5237 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5238 return compType;
5239 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005240
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005241 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005242
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005243 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005244
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005245 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005246 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5247 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005248 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005249 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005250 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005251
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005252 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005253 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005254 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005255
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005256 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005257
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005258 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5259 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5260 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5261 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5262 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5263 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5264 return QualType();
5265 }
5266
5267 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5268 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5269 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5270 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5271 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005272 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005273 return QualType();
5274 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005275
5276 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5277 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5278 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005279 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005280 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005281 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005282 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005283 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005284
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005285 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005286 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005287 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5288 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5289 return QualType();
5290 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005292 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005293 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5294 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5295 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5296 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5297 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5298 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005299 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005300 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5301
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005302 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005303 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005304 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005305
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005306 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005307 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005308 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005309
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005310 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5311 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5312 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5313 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5314 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5315 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5316 return QualType();
5317 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005318
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005319 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5320 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5321 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5322 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005323 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005324 return QualType();
5325 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005326
5327 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5328 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5329 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5330 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5331 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005332 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5333 << rex->getSourceRange()
5334 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005335 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005336
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005337 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5338 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5339 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5340 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5341 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5342 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5343 return QualType();
5344 }
5345 } else {
5346 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5347 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5348 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5349 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5350 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5351 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5352 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5353 return QualType();
5354 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005355 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005356
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005357 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5358 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5359 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5360 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5361 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005362 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005363 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005364
5365 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005366 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5367 }
5368 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005370 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005371}
5372
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005373// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005374QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005375 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005376 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005377 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5378 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005379 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005380
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005381 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5382 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5383 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5384
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005385 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5386 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005387 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5388 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5389 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5390 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5391 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005392 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005393 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005394 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005395
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005396 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005397
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005398 // Sanity-check shift operands
5399 llvm::APSInt Right;
5400 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005401 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5402 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005403 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005404 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5405 else {
5406 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5407 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5408 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5409 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5410 }
5411 }
5412
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005413 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005414 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005415}
5416
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005417static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5418 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5419 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5420 return true;
5421 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5422 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5423 }
5424 return false;
5425}
5426
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005427// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005428QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005429 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005430 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005431
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005432 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005433 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005434 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005435
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005436 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5437 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005438
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005439 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5440 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005441 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5442 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5443 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005444 //
5445 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5446 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5447 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5448 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5449 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5450 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005451 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5452 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005453 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005454 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005455 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005456 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005457 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5458 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005459 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5460 || Opc == BO_LE
5461 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005462 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5463 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5464 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5465 // what is it always going to eval to?
5466 char always_evals_to;
5467 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005468 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005469 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5470 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005471 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005472 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5473 break;
5474 default:
5475 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5476 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5477 break;
5478 }
5479 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5480 << 1 // array
5481 << always_evals_to);
5482 }
5483 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005484 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005485
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005486 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5487 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5488 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5489 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005490
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005491 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5492 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005493 Expr *literalString = 0;
5494 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005495 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005496 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005497 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005498 literalString = lex;
5499 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005500 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5501 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005502 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005503 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005504 literalString = rex;
5505 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5506 }
5507
5508 if (literalString) {
5509 std::string resultComparison;
5510 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005511 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5512 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5513 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5514 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5515 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5516 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005517 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5518 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005519
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005520 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5521 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5522 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005523 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005524 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005525 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005526
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005527 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5528 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5529 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5530 else {
5531 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5532 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5533 }
5534
5535 lType = lex->getType();
5536 rType = rex->getType();
5537
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005538 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005539 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005540
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005541 if (isRelational) {
5542 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005543 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005544 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005545 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005546 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005547 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005548
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005549 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005550 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005551 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005552
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005553 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005554 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005555 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005556 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005557
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005558 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5559 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005560 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005561 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005562 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005563 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005564 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005565
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005566 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005567 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5568 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005569 if (!isRelational &&
5570 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5571 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5572 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005573 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5574 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005575 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5576 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005577 Diag(Loc,
5578 isSFINAEContext()?
5579 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5580 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005581 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005582
5583 if (isSFINAEContext())
5584 return QualType();
5585
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005586 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005587 return ResultTy;
5588 }
5589 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005590 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5591 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5592 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5593 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5594 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5595 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005596 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005597 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005598 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005599 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005600 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005601 if (T.isNull()) {
5602 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5603 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5604 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005605 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005606 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005607 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005608 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005609 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005610 }
5611
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005612 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5613 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005614 return ResultTy;
5615 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005616 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5617 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5618 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5619 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5620 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5621 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5622 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5623 }
5624 } else if (!isRelational &&
5625 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5626 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5627 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5628 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5629 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5630 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5631 }
5632 } else {
5633 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005634 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005635 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005636 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005637 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005638 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005639 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005640 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005641
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005642 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005643 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005644 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005645 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005646 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5647 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005648 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5649 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005650 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5651 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005652 return ResultTy;
5653 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005654 if (LHSIsNull &&
5655 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5656 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005657 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5658 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005659 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5660 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005661 return ResultTy;
5662 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005663
5664 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005665 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005666 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5667 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005668 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5669 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5670 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5671 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5672 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5673 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5674 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5675 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005676 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005677 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005678 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005679 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005680 if (T.isNull()) {
5681 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005682 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005683 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005684 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005685 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005686 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005687 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005688 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005689 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005690
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005691 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5692 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005693 return ResultTy;
5694 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005695
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005696 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005697 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5698 return ResultTy;
5699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005700
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005701 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005702 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005703 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5704 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005705
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005706 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005707 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005708 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005709 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005710 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005711 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005712 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005713 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005714 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005715 if (!isRelational
5716 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5717 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005718 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005719 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005720 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005721 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005722 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5723 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5724 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005725 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005726 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005727 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005728 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005729
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005730 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005731 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005732 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5733 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005734 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005735 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005736 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005737 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005738
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005739 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5740 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005741 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005742 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005743 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005744 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005745 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005746 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005747 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005748 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005749 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5750 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005751 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005752 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005753 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005754 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005755 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5756 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005757 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005758 bool isError = false;
5759 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5760 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5761 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005762 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005763 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005764 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005765 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5766 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5767 isError = true;
5768 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005769 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005770
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005771 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005772 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005773 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005774 if (isError)
5775 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005776 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005777
5778 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005779 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005780 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005781 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005782 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005783 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005784
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005785 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005786 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5787 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005788 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005789 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005790 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005791 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5792 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005793 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005794 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005795 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005796 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005797}
5798
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005799/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005800/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005801/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5802/// types.
5803QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005804 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005805 bool isRelational) {
5806 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5807 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005808 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005809 if (vType.isNull())
5810 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005811
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005812 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5813 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005814
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005815 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5816 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5817 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005818 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005819 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5820 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5821 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005822 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5823 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5824 << 0 // self-
5825 << 2 // "a constant"
5826 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005827 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005828
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005829 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005830 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5831 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005832 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005833 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005834
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005835 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5836 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5837 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005838 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005839 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005840
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005841 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005842 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005843 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005844 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005845 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005846 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5847
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005848 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005849 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005850 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5851}
5852
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005853inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005854 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005855 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5856 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5857 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5858 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5859
5860 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5861 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005862
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005863 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005864
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005865 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005866 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005867 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005868}
5869
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005870inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005871 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5872
5873 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5874 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5875 // is a constant.
5876 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005877 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005878 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005879 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5880 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5881 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5882 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5883 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5884 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5885 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5886 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5887 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005888 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5889 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005890 }
5891 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005892
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005893 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5894 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5895 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005896
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005897 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5898 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005899
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005900 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005901 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005902
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005903 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5904 // non-overloadable operands.
5905
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005906 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5907 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005908 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5909 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5910 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005911 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005912
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005913 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5914 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5915 // The result is a bool.
5916 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005917}
5918
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005919/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5920/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5921/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5922///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005923static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005924 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5925 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5926 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5927 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005928 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005929 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5930 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5931 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5932 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005933 }
5934 }
5935 return false;
5936}
5937
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005938/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5939/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5940static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005941 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005942 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005943 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005944 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5945 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005946 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5947 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005948
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005949 unsigned Diag = 0;
5950 bool NeedType = false;
5951 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005952 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005953 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005954 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5955 NeedType = true;
5956 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005957 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005958 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5959 NeedType = true;
5960 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005961 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005962 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5963 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005964 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5965 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005966 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005967 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5968 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005969 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5970 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005971 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5972 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005973 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005974 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005975 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005976 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005977 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5978 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005979 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005980 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5981 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005982 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5983 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5984 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005985 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5986 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5987 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005988 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5989 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5990 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005991 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005992
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005993 SourceRange Assign;
5994 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5995 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005996 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005997 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005998 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005999 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006000 return true;
6001}
6002
6003
6004
6005// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006006QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6007 SourceLocation Loc,
6008 QualType CompoundType) {
6009 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6010 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006011 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006012
6013 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6014 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006015 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006016 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006017 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006018 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006019 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6020 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6021 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6022 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6023 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6024 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6025 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6026 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6027 }
6028 }
6029
6030 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006031 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6032 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6033 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006034 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006035 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006036 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006037 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006038
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006039 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6040 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6041 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006042 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006043 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6044 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6045 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006046 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6047 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006048 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006049 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006050 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6051 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6052 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006053 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6054 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006055 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006056 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006057 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006058 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006059 }
6060 } else {
6061 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006062 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006063 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006064
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006065 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006066 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006067 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006068
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006069
6070 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6071 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6072 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6073 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6074 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6075 // check.
6076 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006077 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006078 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6079 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6080 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6081 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6082 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6083 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6084 }
6085
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006086 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6087 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006088 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006089 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6090 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006091 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006092 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006093 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006094}
6095
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006096// C99 6.5.17
6097QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006098 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6099
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006100 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006101 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6102 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6103 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006104
6105 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6106 // incomplete in C++).
6107
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006108 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006109}
6110
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006111/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6112/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006113QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006114 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006115 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6116 return Context.DependentTy;
6117
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006118 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6119 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006120
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006121 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6122 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6123 if (!isInc) {
6124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6125 return QualType();
6126 }
6127 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6128 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6129 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006130 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006131 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6132 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006133
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006134 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006135 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006136 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6137 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6138 << Op->getSourceRange();
6139 return QualType();
6140 }
6141
6142 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006143 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006144 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006145 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6147 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6148 return QualType();
6149 }
6150
6151 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006152 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006153 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006154 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006155 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006156 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006157 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006158 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006159 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006160 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6161 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6162 return QualType();
6163 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006164 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006165 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6166 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006167 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006168 } else {
6169 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006170 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006171 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006172 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006173 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006174 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006175 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006176 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006177 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6178 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6179 // operand.
6180 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6181 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006182}
6183
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006184/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006185/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006186/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6187/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6188/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6189/// - &(x) => x
6190/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6191/// - &s.xx => s
6192/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6193/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6194/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6195/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006196static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006197 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006198 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006199 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006200 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006201 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6202 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6203 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006204 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006205 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006206 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006207 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006208 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006209 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6210 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006211 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6212 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6213 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6214 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6215 }
6216 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006217 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006218 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6219 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006220
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006221 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006222 case UO_Real:
6223 case UO_Imag:
6224 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006225 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6226 default:
6227 return 0;
6228 }
6229 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006230 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006231 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006232 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006233 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6234 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006235 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006236 default:
6237 return 0;
6238 }
6239}
6240
6241/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006242/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006243/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006244/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006245/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006246/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006247/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006248QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6249 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006250 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006251 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6252 return Context.OverloadTy;
6253
6254 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6255 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006256
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006257 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6258 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6259 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006260 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006261 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6262 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6263 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6264 }
6265 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6266 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6267 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006268 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006269 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006270
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006271 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006272 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6273 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6274 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6275 if (isSFINAEContext())
6276 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006277 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006278 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006279 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6280 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6281 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6282
6283 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6284 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6285 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6286 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6287 return QualType();
6288 }
6289 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6290 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6291
6292 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6293 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6294 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6295 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6296
6297 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6298 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6299 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6300 << op->getSourceRange();
6301 }
6302
6303 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6304 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6305 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006306 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006307 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006308 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006309 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006310 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6311 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006312 return QualType();
6313 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006314 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006315 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6316 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6317 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006318 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006319 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006320 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006321 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006322 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006323 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006324 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6325 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6326 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6327 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6328 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006329 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6330 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006331 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6332 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006333 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006334 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006335 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6336 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006337 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6338 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006339 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006340 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006341 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6342 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006343 return QualType();
6344 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006345 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006346 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006347 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006348 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006349 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6350 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006351 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006352 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006353 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6354 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006355 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006356 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6357 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6358 return QualType();
6359 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006360
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006361 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6362 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006363 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006364 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006365 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006366 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006367 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006368
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006369 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6370 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6371 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6372 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6373 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6374 }
6375
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006376 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006377 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6378 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006379 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006380}
6381
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006382/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006383QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006384 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6385 return Context.DependentTy;
6386
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006387 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006388 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6389 QualType Result;
6390
6391 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6392 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6393 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6394 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6395 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6396 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6397 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6398 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6399 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006400
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006401 if (Result.isNull()) {
6402 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6403 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6404 return QualType();
6405 }
6406
6407 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006408}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006409
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006410static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006411 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006412 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006413 switch (Kind) {
6414 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006415 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6416 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6417 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6418 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6419 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6420 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6421 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6422 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6423 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6424 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6425 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6426 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6427 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6428 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6429 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6430 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6431 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6432 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6433 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6434 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6435 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6436 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6437 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6438 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6439 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6440 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6441 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6442 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6443 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6444 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6445 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6446 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006447 }
6448 return Opc;
6449}
6450
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006451static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006452 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006453 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006454 switch (Kind) {
6455 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006456 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6457 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6458 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6459 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6460 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6461 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6462 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6463 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6464 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6465 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6466 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006467 }
6468 return Opc;
6469}
6470
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006471/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6472/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6473/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006474ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006475 unsigned Op,
6476 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006477 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006478 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006479 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6480 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6481 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006482
6483 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006484 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006485 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6486 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006487 case BO_PtrMemD:
6488 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006489 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006490 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006491 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006492 case BO_Mul:
6493 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006494 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006495 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006496 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006497 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006498 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6499 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006500 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006501 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6502 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006503 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006504 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6505 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006506 case BO_Shl:
6507 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006508 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6509 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006510 case BO_LE:
6511 case BO_LT:
6512 case BO_GE:
6513 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006514 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006515 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006516 case BO_EQ:
6517 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006518 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006519 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006520 case BO_And:
6521 case BO_Xor:
6522 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006523 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6524 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006525 case BO_LAnd:
6526 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006527 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006528 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006529 case BO_MulAssign:
6530 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006531 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006532 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006533 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6534 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6535 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006536 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006537 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006538 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6539 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6540 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6541 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006542 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006543 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006544 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6545 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6546 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006547 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006548 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006549 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6550 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6551 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006552 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006553 case BO_ShlAssign:
6554 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006555 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6556 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6557 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6558 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006559 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006560 case BO_AndAssign:
6561 case BO_XorAssign:
6562 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006563 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6564 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6565 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6566 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006567 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006568 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006569 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6570 break;
6571 }
6572 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006573 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006574 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006575 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006576 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6577 << ResultTy;
6578 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006579 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006580 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6581 else
6582 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006583 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6584 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006585}
6586
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006587/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6588/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006589static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6590 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006591 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6592 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6593 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006594 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006595 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6596
6597 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6598 return;
6599
6600 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6601 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6602 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006603 return;
6604 }
6605
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006606 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6607 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006608 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006609
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006610 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006611 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006612
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006613 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6614 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6615 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6616 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006617 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006618 return;
6619 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006620
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006621 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006622 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6623 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006624}
6625
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006626/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6627/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6628/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6629/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006630static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006631 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006632 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6633 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6634 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6635 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006636 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006637 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006638 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6639
6640 // Subs are not binary operators.
6641 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6642 return;
6643
6644 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6645 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006646 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6647 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006648 return;
6649
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006650 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006651 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006652 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006653 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6654 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006655 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006656 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006657 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6658 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6659 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6660 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006661 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006662 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006663 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006664 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6665 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006666 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006667 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006668 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6669 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6670 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6671 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006672}
6673
6674/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6675/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6676/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006677static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006678 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006679 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006680 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6681}
6682
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006683// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006684ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006685 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6686 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6687 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006688 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6689 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006690
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006691 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6692 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6693
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006694 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6695}
6696
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006697ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006698 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6699 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006700 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahaniane89d03f2010-09-09 23:01:10 +00006701 (!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) ||
6702 rhs->isTypeDependent()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006703 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006704 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6705 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6706 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6707 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6708 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006709 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006710 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006711 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6712 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6713 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006714
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006715 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6716 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006717 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006718 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006719
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006720 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006721 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006722}
6723
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006724ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006725 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006726 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006727 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006728
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006729 QualType resultType;
6730 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006731 case UO_PreInc:
6732 case UO_PreDec:
6733 case UO_PostInc:
6734 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006735 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006736 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6737 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6738 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6739 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006740 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006741 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006742 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006743 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006744 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006745 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006746 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006747 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006748 case UO_Plus:
6749 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006750 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6751 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006752 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6753 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006754 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6755 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006756 break;
6757 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6758 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6759 break;
6760 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006761 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006762 resultType->isPointerType())
6763 break;
6764
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006765 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6766 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006767 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006768 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6769 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006770 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6771 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006772 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6773 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6774 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006775 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006776 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006777 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006778 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6779 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006780 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006781 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006782 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006783 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006784 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006785 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6786 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006787 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006788 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6789 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006790 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006791 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6792 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006793 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006794 case UO_Real:
6795 case UO_Imag:
6796 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006797 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006798 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006799 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006800 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006801 }
6802 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006803 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006804
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006805 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006806}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006807
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006808ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006809 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6810 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006811 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006812 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006813 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6814 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6815 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6816 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006817 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006818 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006819 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6820 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6821 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006822
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006823 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006824 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006825
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006826 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006827}
6828
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006829// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006830ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006831 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6832 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006833}
6834
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006835/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006836ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006837 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6838 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006839 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006840 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006841
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006842 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6843 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006844 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006845 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006846
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006847 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006848 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6849 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006850}
6851
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006852ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006853Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006854 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006855 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6856 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6857
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006858 bool isFileScope
6859 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006860 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006861 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006862
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006863 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6864 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6865 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006866
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006867 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6868 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6869 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006870
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006871 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6872 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6873 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6874 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6875 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006876
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006877 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006878 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006879 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006880
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006881 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6882 // expressions are not lvalues.
6883
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006884 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006885}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006886
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006887ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006888 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006889 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6890 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006891 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6892 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006893 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006894 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006895
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006896 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6897 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6898 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006899 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006900 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6901 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6902
6903 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6904 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6905 if (!Dependent
6906 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6907 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6908 << TypeRange))
6909 return ExprError();
6910
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006911 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6912 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006913 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6914 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006915 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006916 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6917 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006918
6919 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6920 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6921 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6922 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6923 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6924 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6925 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6926 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6927 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6928 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6929 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6930 if(!AT)
6931 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6932 << CurrentType);
6933 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6934 } else
6935 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6936
6937 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6938 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6939 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6940 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6941 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6942 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6943 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6944 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6945
6946 // Record this array index.
6947 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6948 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6949 continue;
6950 }
6951
6952 // Offset of a field.
6953 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6954 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6955 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6956 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6957 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6958 continue;
6959 }
6960
6961 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6962 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6963 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6964 return ExprError();
6965
6966 // Look for the designated field.
6967 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6968 if (!RC)
6969 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6970 << CurrentType);
6971 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6972
6973 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6974 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6975 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6976 // (clause 9).
6977 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6978 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6979 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6980 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6981 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6982 << CurrentType))
6983 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6984 }
6985
6986 // Look for the field.
6987 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6988 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6989 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6990 if (!MemberDecl)
6991 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6992 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6993 OC.LocEnd));
6994
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006995 // C99 7.17p3:
6996 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6997 //
6998 // We diagnose this as an error.
6999 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7000 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7001 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7002 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7003 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7004 return ExprError();
7005 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007006
7007 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7008 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7009 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7010 do {
7011 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7012 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7013 }
7014
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007015 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7016 // the base class indirections.
7017 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7018 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007019 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007020 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7021 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7022 B != BEnd; ++B)
7023 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7024 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007025
7026 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007027 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7028 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7029 unsigned n = Path.size();
7030 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7031 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7032 } else {
7033 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7034 }
7035 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7036 }
7037
7038 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7039 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7040 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7041}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007042
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007043ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007044 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7045 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007046 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007047 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7048 unsigned NumComponents,
7049 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7050
7051 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7052 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7053 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7054 return ExprError();
7055
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007056 if (!ArgTInfo)
7057 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7058
7059 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7060 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007061}
7062
7063
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007064ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007065 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007066 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007067 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7068 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7069 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7070 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007071
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007072 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007073
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007074 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7075}
7076
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007077ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007078Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7079 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7080 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7081 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007082 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7083 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7084 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7085 return ExprError();
7086 }
7087
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007088 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007089 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007090}
7091
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007092
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007093ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007094 Expr *CondExpr,
7095 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007096 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007097 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7098
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007099 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007100 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007101 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007102 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007103 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007104 } else {
7105 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7106 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7107 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7108 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007109 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7110 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7111 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007112
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007113 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7114 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007115 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7116 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007117 }
7118
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007119 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007120 resType, RPLoc,
7121 resType->isDependentType(),
7122 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007123}
7124
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007125//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7126// Clang Extensions.
7127//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7128
7129/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007130void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007131 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7132 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7133 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007134 if (BlockScope)
7135 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7136 else
7137 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007138}
7139
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007140void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007141 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007142 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007143
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007144 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007145 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007146 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007147
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007148 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007149 QualType RetTy;
7150 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007151 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007152 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007153 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007154 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7155 } else {
7156 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007157 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007158 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007159
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007160 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007161
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007162 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7163 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7164 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007165 return;
7166 }
7167
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007168 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7169 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7170 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7171 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7172 return;
7173 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007174
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007175 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007176 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7177 // ^ * { ... }
7178 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007179 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7180 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007181
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007182 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007183 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007184 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7185 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7186 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7187 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007188 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7189 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7190 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7191 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7192 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007193 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007194 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007195
7196 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7197 // ^ fntype { ... }
7198 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7199 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7200 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7201 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7202 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7203 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7204 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007205 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007206 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007207 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007208
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007209 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7210 if (!Params.empty())
7211 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007212
7213 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007214 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007215
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007216 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007217 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7218 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7219 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7220 }
7221
7222 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7223 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007224 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007225 return;
7226
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007227 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7228 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7229
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007230 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007231 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7232 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7233
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007234 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007235 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7236 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7237 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7238
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007239 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007240 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007241 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007242}
7243
7244/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7245/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7246void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007247 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007248 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007249 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007250 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007251}
7252
7253/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7254/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007255ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007256 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007257 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7258 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7259 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007260
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007261 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007262
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007263 PopDeclContext();
7264
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007265 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007266 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7267 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007268
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007269 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007270 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007271
7272 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7273 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7274 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7275
7276 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7277 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7278
7279 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7280 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7281 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7282 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7283
7284 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7285 // preserve its sugar structure.
7286 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7287 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7288 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7289
7290 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7291 } else {
7292 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7293 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7294 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7295 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7296 FPT->isVariadic(),
7297 /*quals*/ 0,
7298 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7299 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7300 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7301 FPT->exception_begin(),
7302 Ext);
7303 }
7304
7305 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7306 } else {
7307 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7308 false, false, 0, 0,
7309 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7310 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007311
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007312 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007313 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7314 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007315 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007316
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007317 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007318 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007319 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007320
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007321 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007322
7323 bool Good = true;
7324 // Check goto/label use.
7325 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7326 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7327 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7328
7329 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7330 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7331 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7332 continue;
7333
7334 // Emit error.
7335 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7336 Good = false;
7337 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007338 if (!Good) {
7339 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007340 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007341 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007342
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007343 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7344 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7345
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007346 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007347 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7348 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007349 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007350
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007351 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007352 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007353}
7354
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007355ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007356 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007357 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007358 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7359 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007360 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007361}
7362
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007363ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007364 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007365 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007366 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007367
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007368 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007369
7370 // Get the va_list type
7371 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007372 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7373 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7374 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7375 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007376 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007377 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7378 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7379 } else {
7380 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7381 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007382 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007383 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007384 return ExprError();
7385 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007386
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007387 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7388 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007389 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7390 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007391 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007392 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007393
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007394 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007395 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007396
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007397 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7398 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007399}
7400
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007401ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007402 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7403 // pointers on the target.
7404 QualType Ty;
7405 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7406 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7407 else
7408 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7409
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007410 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007411}
7412
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007413static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007414 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007415 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7416 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007417
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007418 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7419 if (!PT)
7420 return;
7421
7422 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7423 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7424 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7425 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7426 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7427 return;
7428 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007429
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007430 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7431 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7432 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7433 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007434
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007435 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007436}
7437
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007438bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7439 SourceLocation Loc,
7440 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007441 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7442 bool *Complained) {
7443 if (Complained)
7444 *Complained = false;
7445
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007446 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7447 bool isInvalid = false;
7448 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007449 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007450
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007451 switch (ConvTy) {
7452 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7453 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007454 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007455 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7456 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007457 case IntToPointer:
7458 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7459 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007460 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007461 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007462 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7463 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007464 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7465 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7466 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007467 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7468 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7469 break;
7470 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007471 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7472 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7473 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7474 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7475 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7476 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7477 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7478 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7479 // C++ semantics.
7480 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7481 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7482 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007483 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7484 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007485 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007486 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007487 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007488 case IntToBlockPointer:
7489 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7490 break;
7491 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007492 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007493 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007494 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007495 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007496 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7497 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7498 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007499 case IncompatibleVectors:
7500 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7501 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007502 case Incompatible:
7503 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7504 isInvalid = true;
7505 break;
7506 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007507
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007508 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7509 switch (Action) {
7510 case AA_Assigning:
7511 case AA_Initializing:
7512 // The destination type comes first.
7513 FirstType = DstType;
7514 SecondType = SrcType;
7515 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007516
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007517 case AA_Returning:
7518 case AA_Passing:
7519 case AA_Converting:
7520 case AA_Sending:
7521 case AA_Casting:
7522 // The source type comes first.
7523 FirstType = SrcType;
7524 SecondType = DstType;
7525 break;
7526 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007527
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007528 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007529 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007530 if (Complained)
7531 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007532 return isInvalid;
7533}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007534
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007535bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007536 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7537 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7538 if (Result)
7539 *Result = ICEResult;
7540 return false;
7541 }
7542
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007543 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7544
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007545 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007546 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7547 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7548
7549 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7550 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7551 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7552 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7553 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7554 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7555 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007556
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007557 return true;
7558 }
7559
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007560 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7561 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007562
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007563 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7564 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7565 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007566
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007567 if (Result)
7568 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7569 return false;
7570}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007571
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007572void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007573Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007574 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7575 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007576}
7577
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007578void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007579Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7580 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7581 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7582 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007583
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007584 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7585 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7586 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7587 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7588 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007589 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007590 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7591 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7592 I != IEnd; ++I)
7593 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7594 }
7595
7596 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7597 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7598 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7599 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7600 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7601 I != IEnd; ++I)
7602 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7603 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007604 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007605
7606 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7607 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7608 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7609 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007610 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007611 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7612 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7613 ExprTemporaries.end());
7614
7615 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7616 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007617}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007618
7619/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7620///
7621/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7622/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7623/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7624/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7625///
7626/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7627///
7628/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7629void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7630 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007631
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007632 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007633 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007634
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007635 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7636 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7637 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7638 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007639 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007640 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007641 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007642 return;
7643 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007644
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007645 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7646 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007647
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007648 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7649 // an instantiation.
7650 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7651 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007652
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007653 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007654 case Unevaluated:
7655 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7656 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007657
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007658 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7659 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7660 // "used"; handle this below.
7661 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007662
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007663 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7664 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7665 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7666 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007667 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007668 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007669
7670 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7671 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7672 // containing expression is used.
7673 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007674 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007675
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007676 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007677 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007678 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007679 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007680 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7681 return;
7682 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7683 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007684 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007685 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007686 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007687 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7688 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007689
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007690 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007691 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007692 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007693 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007694 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7695 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007696 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7697 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7698 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007699 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007700 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007701 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7702 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007703 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007704 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007706 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007707 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007708 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7709 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7710 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7711 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7712 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007713 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007714 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007715 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007716 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007717 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7718 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7719 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007720 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007721 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007722 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7723 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007724
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007725 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7726 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7727 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7728 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7729 Loc));
7730 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007731 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007732 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007733 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7734 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7735 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007736 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007737 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7738 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007739
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007740 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007741
7742 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7743 if (CurContext != Function)
7744 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007745
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007746 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007747 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007748
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007749 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007750 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007751 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007752 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7753 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7754 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7755 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7756 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7757 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007758 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007759 }
7760 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007761
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007762 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007763
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007764 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007765 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007766 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007767}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007768
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007769namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007770 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007771 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007772 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007773 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7774 Sema &S;
7775 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007776
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007777 public:
7778 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007779
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007780 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007781
7782 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7783 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007784 };
7785}
7786
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007787bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7788 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007789 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7790 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7791 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007792
7793 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007794}
7795
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007796bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007797 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7798 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7799 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007800 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7801 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007802 }
7803
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007804 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007805}
7806
7807void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7808 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007809 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007810}
7811
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007812namespace {
7813 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7814 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7815 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7816 Sema &S;
7817
7818 public:
7819 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7820
7821 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7822
7823 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7824 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7825 }
7826
7827 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7828 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007829 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007830 }
7831
7832 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7833 if (E->getConstructor())
7834 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7835 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7836 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7837 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7838 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007839 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007840 }
7841
7842 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7843 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7844 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007845 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7846 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7847 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7848 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7849 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7850 }
7851
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007852 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007853 }
7854
7855 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7856 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007857 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007858 }
7859
7860 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7861 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7862 }
7863 };
7864}
7865
7866/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7867/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7868void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
7869 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
7870}
7871
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007872/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7873/// of the program being compiled.
7874///
7875/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007876/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007877/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7878/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7879/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7880/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007881/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007882/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007883///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007884/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7885/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7886/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7887/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007888bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007889 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7890 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7891 case Unevaluated:
7892 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7893 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007894
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007895 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007896 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007897 Diag(Loc, PD);
7898 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007899
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007900 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7901 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7902 break;
7903 }
7904
7905 return false;
7906}
7907
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007908bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7909 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7910 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7911 return false;
7912
7913 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7914 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7915 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7916 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007917
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007918 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007919 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007920 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7921 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007922 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007923 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7924 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7925 return true;
7926
7927 return false;
7928}
7929
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007930// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7931// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7932void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7933 SourceLocation Loc;
7934
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007935 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7936
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007937 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7938 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007939 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007940 return;
7941
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007942 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7943 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7944 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7945 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7946
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007947 // self = [<foo> init...]
7948 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7949 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7950 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7951
7952 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7953 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7954 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7955 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7956 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007957
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007958 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7959 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7960 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7961 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7962 return;
7963
7964 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7965 } else {
7966 // Not an assignment.
7967 return;
7968 }
7969
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007970 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007971 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007972
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007973 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007974 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007975 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007976 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7977 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7978 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007979}
7980
7981bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7982 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7983
7984 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007985 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007986
7987 QualType T = E->getType();
7988
7989 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7990 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7991 return true;
7992 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7993 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7994 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7995 return true;
7996 }
7997 }
7998
7999 return false;
8000}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008001
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008002ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8003 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008004 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008005 return ExprError();
8006
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008007 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008008 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008009
8010 return Owned(Sub);
8011}